xref: /freebsd/contrib/wpa/src/drivers/nl80211_copy.h (revision 7937bfbc0ca53fe7cdd0d54414f9296e273a518e)
1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2023 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59 
60 /**
61  * DOC: Station handling
62  *
63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67  * to.
68  *
69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70  * capabilities.
71  *
72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75  *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78  *    time mark it authorized.
79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82  *
83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84  */
85 
86 /**
87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88  *
89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93  * for various reasons.
94  *
95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101  * for doing that.
102  *
103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106  *
107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113  *
114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118  *
119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120  * below.
121  */
122 
123 /**
124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125  *
126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130  *
131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
134  *
135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138  * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142  *
143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151  *
152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
154  */
155 
156 /**
157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
158  *
159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162  * and power consumption.
163  *
164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167  * following events occur.
168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit.
171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172  *
173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174  * rule.
175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177  * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
179  */
180 
181 /**
182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183  *
184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186  * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191  *
192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195  * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196  * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197  * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198  * not present.
199  *
200  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202  * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207  *
208  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211  */
212 
213 /**
214  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215  *
216  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
217  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231  *
232  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234  * up a connection or after roaming.
235  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241  *
242  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
243  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249  */
250 
251 /**
252  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253  *
254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256  * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257  * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258  *
259  * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261  * respectively.
262  */
263 
264 /**
265  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266  *
267  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273  * that main netdev.
274  *
275  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278  */
279 
280 /**
281  * DOC: TID configuration
282  *
283  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285  *
286  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289  *
290  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293  * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values
295  * will be overwritten.
296  *
297  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection
298  * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300  * the interface goes down.
301  */
302 
303 /**
304  * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305  *
306  * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307  *
308  * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310  * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311  * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312  * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313  *
314  * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315  * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316  * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317  * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321  *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322  *
323  * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324  */
325 
326 /**
327  * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328  *
329  * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple
330  * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331  * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332  * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333  * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334  * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335  */
336 
337 /**
338  * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload
339  *
340  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate
341  * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is
342  * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and
343  * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK.
344  */
345 
346 /**
347  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
348  *
349  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
350  *
351  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
352  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
353  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
354  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
355  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
356  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
357  *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
358  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
359  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
360  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
361  *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
362  *	compatibility only.
363  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
364  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
365  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
366  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
367  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
368  *
369  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
370  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
371  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
372  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
373  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
374  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
375  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
376  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
377  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
378  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
379  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
380  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
381  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
382  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
383  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
384  *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
385  *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
386  *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
387  *
388  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
389  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
390  *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
391  *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
393  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
394  *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
395  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
397  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
398  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
399  *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
400  *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
401  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
402  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
403  *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
404  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
405  *
406  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
407  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
408  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
409  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
410  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
412  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
413  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
414  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
415  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
416  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
417  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
418  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
419  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
420  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
421  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
422  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
423  *	attributes determining channel width.
424  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
425  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
426  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
427  *
428  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
429  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
430  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
431  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
432  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
433  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
434  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
435  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
436  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
437  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
438  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
439  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
440  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
441  *	frame).
442  *
443  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
444  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
445  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
446  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
447  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
448  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
449  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
450  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
451  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
452  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
453  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
454  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
455  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
456  *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
457  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
458  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
459  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
460  *
461  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
462  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
463  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
464  *	global regdomain will be returned.
465  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
466  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
467  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
468  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
469  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
470  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
471  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
472  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
473  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
474  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
475  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
476  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
477  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
478  * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
479  * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
480  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
481  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
482  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
483  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
484  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
485  * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
486  * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
487  *
488  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
489  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
490  *
491  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
492  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
493  *
494  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
495  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
496  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
497  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
498  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
499  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
500  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
501  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
502  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
503  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
504  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
505  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
506  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
507  *
508  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
509  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
510  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
511  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
512  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
513  *	be used.
514  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
515  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
516  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
517  *	partial scan results may be available
518  *
519  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
520  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
521  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
522  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
523  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
524  *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
525  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
526  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
527  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
528  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
529  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
530  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
531  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
532  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
533  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
534  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
535  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
536  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
537  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
538  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
539  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
540  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
541  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
542  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
543  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
544  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
545  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
546  *	results available.
547  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
548  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
549  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
550  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
551  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
552  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
553  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
554  *
555  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
556  *      or noise level
557  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
558  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
559  *
560  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
561  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
562  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
563  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
564  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
565  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
566  *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
567  *	ESS.
568  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
569  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
570  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
571  *	authentication.
572  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
573  *
574  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
575  * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
576  * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
577  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
578  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
579  * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
580  * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
581  * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
582  * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
583  * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
584  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
585  * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
586  * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
587  * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
588  * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
589  * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
590  * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
591  * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
592  * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
593  * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
594  * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
595  * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
596  * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
597  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
598  * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
599  * 	the beacon hint was processed.
600  *
601  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
602  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
603  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
604  *	authentication process.
605  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
606  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
607  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
608  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
609  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
610  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the
611  *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
612  *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
613  *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
614  *	to the frame.
615  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
616  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
617  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
618  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
619  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
620  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
621  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
622  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
623  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
624  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
625  *	pending authentication timed out).
626  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
627  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
628  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
629  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
630  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
631  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
632  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
633  *	included).
634  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
635  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
636  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
637  *	primitives).
638  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
639  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
640  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
641  *
642  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
643  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
644  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
645  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
646  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
647  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
648  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
649  *
650  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
651  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
652  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
653  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
654  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
655  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
656  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
657  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
658  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
659  *	determined by the network interface.
660  *
661  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
662  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
663  *	to the driver.
664  *
665  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
666  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
667  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
668  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
669  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
670  *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
671  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
672  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
673  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
674  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
675  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
676  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
677  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
678  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
679  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
680  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
681  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
682  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
683  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
684  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
685  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
686  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
687  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
688  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
689  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
690  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
691  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
692  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
693  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
694  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
695  *	a different BSS is desired.
696  *	Background scan period can optionally be
697  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
698  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
699  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
700  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
701  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
702  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
703  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
704  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
705  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
706  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
707  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
708  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
709  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
710  *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
711  *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
712  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
713  *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
714  *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
715  *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
716  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
717  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
718  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
719  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
720  *
721  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
722  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
723  *
724  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
725  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
726  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
727  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
728  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
729  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
730  *	frequency for the operation.
731  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
732  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
733  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
734  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
735  *	radio).
736  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
737  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
738  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
739  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
740  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
741  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
742  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
743  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
744  *	uniquely identify the request.
745  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
746  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
747  *
748  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
749  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
750  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
751  *
752  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
753  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
754  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
755  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
756  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
757  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
758  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
759  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
760  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
761  *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
762  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
763  *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
764  *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
765  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
766  *	backward compatibility
767  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
768  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
769  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
770  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
771  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
772  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
773  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
774  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
775  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
776  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
777  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
778  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
779  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
780  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
781  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
782  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
783  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
784  *	is used during CSA period.
785  *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
786  *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
787  *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
788  *	lower layers.
789  *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
790  *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
791  *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
792  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
793  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
794  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
795  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
796  *	wait time.
797  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
798  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
799  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
800  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
801  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
802  *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
803  *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
804  *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
805  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
806  *	backward compatibility.
807  *
808  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
809  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
810  *
811  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
812  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
813  *	levels.
814  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
815  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
816  *	reached.
817  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
818  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
819  *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
820  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
821  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
822  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
823  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
824  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
825  *	precedence when they are used.
826  *
827  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
828  *	(no longer supported).
829  *
830  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
831  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
832  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
833  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
834  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
835  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
836  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
837  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
838  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
839  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
840  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
841  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
842  *	command, the feature is disabled.
843  *
844  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
845  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
846  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
847  *	network is determined by the network interface.
848  *
849  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
850  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
851  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
852  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
853  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
854  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
855  *
856  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
857  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
858  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
859  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
860  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
861  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
862  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
863  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
864  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
865  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
866  *      depending on the authentication result.
867  *
868  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
869  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
870  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
871  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
872  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
873  *	more background information, see
874  *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
875  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
876  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
877  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
878  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
879  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
880  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
881  *
882  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
883  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
884  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
885  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
886  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
887  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
888  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
889  *
890  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
891  *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
892  *
893  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
894  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
895  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
896  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
897  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
898  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
899  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
900  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
901  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
902  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
903  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
904  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
905  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
906  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
907  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
908  *
909  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
910  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
911  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
912  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
913  *	is received.
914  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
915  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
916  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
917  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
918  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
919  *
920  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
921  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
922  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
923  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
924  *
925  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
926  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
927  *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
928  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
929  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
930  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
931  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
932  *
933  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
934  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
935  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
936  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
937  *
938  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
939  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
940  *
941  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
942  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
943  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
944  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
945  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
946  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
947  *
948  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
949  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
950  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
951  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
952  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
953  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
954  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
955  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
956  *
957  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
958  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
959  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
960  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
961  *	public action frame TX.
962  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
963  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
964  *
965  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
966  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
967  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
968  *	is used for this.
969  *
970  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
971  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
972  *
973  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
974  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
975  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
976  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
977  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
978  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
979  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
980  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
981  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
982  *
983  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
984  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
985  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
986  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
987  *	while operating on this channel.
988  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
989  *	event.
990  *
991  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
992  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
993  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
994  *
995  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
996  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
997  *
998  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
999  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
1000  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
1001  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
1002  *
1003  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
1004  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
1005  *	complete.
1006  *
1007  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
1008  *	return back to normal.
1009  *
1010  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1011  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1012  *
1013  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1014  *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1015  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1016  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1017  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1018  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1019  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1020  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1021  *	switch is complete.
1022  *
1023  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1024  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1025  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1026  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1027  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1028  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1029  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1030  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1031  *
1032  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1033  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1034  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1035  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1036  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1037  *
1038  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1039  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1040  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1041  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1042  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1043  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1044  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1045  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1046  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1047  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1048  *	fail even if the check was successful.
1049  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1050  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1051  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1052  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1053  *
1054  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1055  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1056  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1057  *
1058  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1059  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1060  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1061  *	network is determined by the network interface.
1062  *
1063  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1064  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1065  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1066  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1067  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1068  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1069  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1070  *	AP.
1071  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1072  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1073  *	when this command completes.
1074  *
1075  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1076  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1077  *	management.
1078  *
1079  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1080  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1081  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1082  *
1083  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1084  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1085  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1086  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1087  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1088  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1089  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1090  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1091  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1092  *	added.
1093  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1094  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1095  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1096  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1097  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1098  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1099  *	of the function upon success.
1100  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1101  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1102  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1103  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1104  *	which just terminated.
1105  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1106  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1107  *	the response to this command.
1108  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1109  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1110  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1111  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1112  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1113  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1114  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1115  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1116  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1117  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1118  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1119  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1120  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1121  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1122  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1123  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1124  *
1125  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1126  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1127  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1128  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1129  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1130  *
1131  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1132  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1133  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1134  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1135  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1136  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1137  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1138  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was
1139  *	completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload
1140  *	should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with
1141  *	%NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT
1142  *	should be indicated instead.
1143  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1144  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1145  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1146  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1147  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1148  *	802.11 headers.
1149  *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1150  *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1151  *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1152  *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1153  *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1154  *	address of that link.
1155  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1156  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1157  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1158  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1159  *
1160  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1161  *
1162  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1163  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1164  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1165  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1166  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1167  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1168  *
1169  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1170  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1171  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1172  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1173  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1174  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1175  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1176  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1177  *	command interface.
1178  *
1179  *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1180  *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1181  *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1182  *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1183  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1184  *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1185  *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1186  *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1187  *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1188  *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1189  *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1190  *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1191  *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1192  *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1193  *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1194  *	authentication.
1195  *
1196  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1197  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1198  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1199  *
1200  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1201  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1202  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1203  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1204  *
1205  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1206  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1207  *
1208  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1209  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1210  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1211  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1212  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1213  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1214  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1215  *	the netlink extended ack message.
1216  *
1217  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1218  *
1219  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1220  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1221  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1222  *	buffer size.
1223  *
1224  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1225  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1226  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1227  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1228  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1229  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1230  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1231  *
1232  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1233  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1234  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1235  *	determining the width and type.
1236  *
1237  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1238  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1239  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1240  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1241  *
1242  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1243  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1244  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1245  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1246  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1247  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1248  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1249  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1250  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1251  *	rate selection.
1252  *
1253  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1254  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1255  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1256  *
1257  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1258  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1259  *
1260  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1261  *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1262  *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1263  *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1264  *
1265  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1266  *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1267  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1268  *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1269  *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1270  *
1271  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1272  *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1273  *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1274  *
1275  * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1276  *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1277  *
1278  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1279  *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1280  *
1281  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1282  *	started
1283  *
1284  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1285  *	been aborted
1286  *
1287  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1288  *	has completed
1289  *
1290  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1291  *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1292  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1293  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1294  *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1295  *
1296  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1297  *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1298  *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1299  *      specify the timeout value.
1300  *
1301  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1302  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1303  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1304  *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1305  *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1306  *
1307  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1308  * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1309  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1310  *
1311  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
1312  *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1313  *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
1314  *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
1315  *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
1316  *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
1317  *	HW timestamping.
1318  *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
1319  *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
1320  *
1321  * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD
1322  *	setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with
1323  *	Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide
1324  *	information about the removed STA MLD setup links.
1325  *
1326  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1327  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1328  */
1329 enum nl80211_commands {
1330 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1331 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1332 
1333 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1334 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1335 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1336 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1337 
1338 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1339 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1340 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1341 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1342 
1343 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1344 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1345 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1346 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1347 
1348 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1349 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1350 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1351 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1352 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1353 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1354 
1355 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1356 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1357 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1358 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1359 
1360 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1361 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1362 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1363 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1364 
1365 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1366 
1367 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1368 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1369 
1370 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1371 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1372 
1373 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1374 
1375 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1376 
1377 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1378 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1379 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1380 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1381 
1382 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1383 
1384 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1385 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1386 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1387 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1388 
1389 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1390 
1391 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1392 
1393 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1394 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1395 
1396 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1397 
1398 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1399 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1400 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1401 
1402 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1403 
1404 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1405 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1406 
1407 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1408 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1409 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1410 
1411 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1412 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1413 
1414 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1415 
1416 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1417 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1418 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1419 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1420 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1421 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1422 
1423 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1424 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1425 
1426 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1427 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1428 
1429 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1430 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1431 
1432 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1433 
1434 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1435 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1436 
1437 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1438 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1439 
1440 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1441 
1442 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1443 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1444 
1445 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1446 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1447 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1448 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1449 
1450 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1451 
1452 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1453 
1454 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1455 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1456 
1457 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1458 
1459 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1460 
1461 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1462 
1463 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1464 
1465 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1466 
1467 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1468 
1469 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1470 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1471 
1472 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1473 
1474 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1475 
1476 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1477 
1478 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1479 
1480 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1481 
1482 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1483 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1484 
1485 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1486 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1487 
1488 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1489 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1490 
1491 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1492 
1493 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1494 
1495 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1496 
1497 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1498 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1499 
1500 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1501 
1502 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1503 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1504 
1505 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1506 
1507 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1508 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1509 
1510 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1511 
1512 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1513 
1514 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1515 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1516 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1517 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1518 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1519 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1520 
1521 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1522 
1523 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1524 
1525 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1526 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1527 
1528 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1529 
1530 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1531 
1532 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1533 
1534 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1535 
1536 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1537 
1538 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1539 
1540 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1541 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1542 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1543 
1544 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1545 
1546 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1547 
1548 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1549 
1550 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1551 
1552 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1553 
1554 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1555 
1556 	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1557 
1558 	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1559 
1560 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1561 
1562 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1563 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1564 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1565 
1566 	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1567 
1568 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1569 
1570 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1571 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1572 
1573 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1574 	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1575 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1576 
1577 	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
1578 
1579 	NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED,
1580 
1581 	/* add new commands above here */
1582 
1583 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1584 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1585 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1586 };
1587 
1588 /*
1589  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1590  * here
1591  */
1592 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1593 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1594 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1595 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1596 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1597 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1598 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1599 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1600 
1601 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1602 
1603 /* source-level API compatibility */
1604 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1605 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1606 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1607 
1608 /**
1609  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1610  *
1611  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1612  *
1613  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1614  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1615  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1616  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1617  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1618  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1619  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1620  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1621  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1622  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1623  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1624  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1625  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1626  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1627  *	operating channel center frequency.
1628  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1629  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1630  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1631  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1632  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1633  *		this attribute)
1634  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1635  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1636  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1637  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1638  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1639  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1640  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1641  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1642  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1643  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1644  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1645  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1646  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1647  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1648  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1649  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1650  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1651  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1652  *
1653  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1654  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1655  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1656  *
1657  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1658  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1659  *
1660  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1661  *
1662  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1663  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1664  *	keys
1665  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1666  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1667  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1668  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1669  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1670  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1671  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1672  *	default management key
1673  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1674  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1675  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1676  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1677  *
1678  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1679  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1681  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1682  *
1683  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1684  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1685  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1686  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1687  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1688  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1689  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1690  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1691  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1692  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1693  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1694  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1695  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1696  *
1697  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1698  *	consisting of a nested array.
1699  *
1700  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1701  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1702  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1703  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1705  * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1706  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1707  *
1708  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1709  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1710  *
1711  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1712  * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1713  * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1714  * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1715  * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1716  * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1717  * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1718  * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1719  * 	to a specific alpha2.
1720  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1721  *	rules.
1722  *
1723  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1724  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1725  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1727  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1728  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1729  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1730  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1731  *
1732  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1733  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1734  *
1735  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1736  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1737  *	of the interface mode.
1738  *
1739  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1740  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1741  *
1742  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1743  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1744  *
1745  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1746  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1747  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1748  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1749  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1750  *	that can be added to a scan request
1751  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1752  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1753  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1754  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1755  *
1756  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1757  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1758  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1759  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1760  *
1761  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1762  * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1763  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1764  * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1765  *
1766  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1767  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1768  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1769  *
1770  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1771  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1772  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1773  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1774  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1775  *	represented as a u32
1776  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1777  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1778  *
1779  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1780  *	a u32
1781  *
1782  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1783  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1784  * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1785  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1786  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1787  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1788  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1789  * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1790  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1791  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1792  *
1793  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1794  *	cipher suites
1795  *
1796  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1797  *	for other networks on different channels
1798  *
1799  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1800  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1801  *
1802  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1803  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1804  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1805  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1806  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1807  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1808  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1809  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1810  *
1811  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1812  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1813  *
1814  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1815  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1816  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1817  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1818  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1819  *	default in station mode.
1820  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1821  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1822  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1823  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1824  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1825  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1826  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1827  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1828  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1829  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1830  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1831  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1832  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1833  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1834  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1835  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1836  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1837  *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1838  *	frames are not forwared over the control port.
1839  *
1840  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1841  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1842  *
1843  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1844  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1845  *	a local disconnect request.
1846  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1847  *	event (u16)
1848  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1849  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1850  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1851  *
1852  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1853  *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1854  *	(an array of u32).
1855  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1856  *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1857  *	u32).
1858  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1859  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1860  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1861  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1862  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1863  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1864  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1865  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1866  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1867  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1868  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1869  *
1870  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1871  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1872  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1873  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1874  *
1875  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1876  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1877  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1878  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1879  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1880  *
1881  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1882  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1883  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1884  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1885  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1886  *
1887  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1888  *
1889  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1890  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1891  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1892  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1893  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1894  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1895  *	completely from scratch.
1896  *
1897  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1898  *
1899  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1900  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1901  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1902  *
1903  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1904  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1905  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1906  *
1907  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1908  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1909  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1910  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1911  *
1912  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1913  *
1914  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1915  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1916  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1917  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1918  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1919  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1920  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1921  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1922  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1923  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1924  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1925  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1926  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1927  *
1928  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1929  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1930  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1931  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1932  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1933  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1934  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1935  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1936  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1937  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1938  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1939  *
1940  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1941  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1942  *
1943  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1944  *
1945  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1946  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1947  *
1948  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1949  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1950  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1951  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1952  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1953  *
1954  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1955  *	connected to this BSS.
1956  *
1957  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1958  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1959  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1960  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1961  *      for non-automatic settings.
1962  *
1963  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1964  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1965  *
1966  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1967  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1968  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1969  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1970  *
1971  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1972  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1973  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1974  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1975  *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
1976  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1977  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1978  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
1979  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1980  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1981  *
1982  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1983  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1984  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1985  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1986  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1987  *
1988  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1989  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1990  *
1991  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1992  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1993  *
1994  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1995  *
1996  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
1997  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
1998  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
1999  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
2000  *	nl80211 capability flag.
2001  *
2002  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
2003  *
2004  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
2005  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
2006  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
2007  *
2008  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
2009  *	changed once the mesh is active.
2010  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
2011  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
2012  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
2013  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
2014  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
2015  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
2016  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
2017  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
2018  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
2019  *
2020  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
2021  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
2022  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
2023  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
2024  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
2025  *	triggers.
2026  *
2027  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2028  *	cycles, in msecs.
2029  *
2030  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2031  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2032  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2033  *	pass-thru filter rules.
2034  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2035  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2036  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2037  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2038  *	able to ignore them by itself.
2039  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2040  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2041  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2042  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2043  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2044  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2045  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2046  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2047  *
2048  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2049  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2050  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2051  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2052  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2053  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2054  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2055  *
2056  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2057  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2058  *
2059  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2060  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2061  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2062  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2063  *
2064  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2065  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2066  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2067  *
2068  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2069  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2070  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2071  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2072  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2073  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2074  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2075  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2076  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2077  *
2078  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2079  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2080  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2081  *	as AP.
2082  *
2083  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2084  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2085  *
2086  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2087  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2088  *
2089  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2090  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2091  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2092  *	applications use this attribute.
2093  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2094  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2095  *
2096  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2097  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2098  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2099  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2100  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2101  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2102  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2103  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2104  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2105  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2106  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2107  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2108  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2109  *
2110  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2111  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2112  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2113  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2114  *
2115  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2116  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2117  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2118  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2119  *
2120  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2121  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2122  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2123  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2124  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2125  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2126  *
2127  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2128  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2129  *	to be filled by the FW.
2130  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2131  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2132  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2133  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2134  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2135  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2136  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2137  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2138  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2139  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2140  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2141  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2142  *      The values that may be configured are:
2143  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2144  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2145  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2146  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2147  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2148  *
2149  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2150  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2151  *    to one DFS region.
2152  *
2153  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2154  *      up to 16 TIDs.
2155  *
2156  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2157  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2158  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2159  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2160  *	capability to timeout the stations.
2161  *
2162  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2163  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2164  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2165  *
2166  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2167  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2168  *
2169  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2170  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2171  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2172  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2173  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2174  *
2175  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2176  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2177  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2178  *
2179  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2180  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2181  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2182  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2183  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2184  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2185  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2186  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2187  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2188  *	consistent.
2189  *
2190  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2191  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2192  *
2193  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2194  *
2195  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2196  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2197  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2198  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2199  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2200  *	no change is made.
2201  *
2202  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2203  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2204  *
2205  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2206  *	carried in a u32 attribute
2207  *
2208  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2209  *	MAC ACL.
2210  *
2211  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2212  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2213  *	ACL.
2214  *
2215  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2216  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2217  *
2218  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2219  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2220  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2221  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2222  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2223  *
2224  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2225  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2226  *
2227  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2228  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2229  *	and PU-APSD.
2230  *
2231  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2232  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2233  *
2234  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2235  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2236  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2237  *
2238  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2239  *
2240  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2241  *	Element
2242  *
2243  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2244  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2245  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2246  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2247  *
2248  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2249  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2250  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2251  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2252  *
2253  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2254  *
2255  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2256  *	until the channel switch event.
2257  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2258  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2259  *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2260  *	was requested by the AP.
2261  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2262  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2263  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2264  *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2265  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2266  *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2267  *
2268  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2269  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2270  *
2271  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2272  *
2273  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2274  *      operating classes.
2275  *
2276  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2277  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2278  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2279  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2280  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2281  *	IBSS network.
2282  *
2283  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2284  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2285  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2286  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2287  *
2288  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2289  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2290  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2291  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2292  *	u8 attribute.
2293  *
2294  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2295  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2296  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2297  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2298  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2299  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2300  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2301  *
2302  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2303  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2304  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2305  *
2306  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2307  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2308  *
2309  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2310  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2311  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2312  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2313  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2314  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2315  *
2316  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2317  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2318  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2319  *	supported number of csa counters.
2320  *
2321  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2322  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2323  *
2324  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2325  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2326  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2327  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2328  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2329  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2330  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2331  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2332  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2333  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2334  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2335  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2336  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2337  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2338  *	multicast group.
2339  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2340  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2341  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2342  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2343  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2344  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2345  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2346  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2347  *
2348  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2349  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2350  *
2351  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2352  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2353  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2354  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2355  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2356  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2357  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2358  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2359  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2360  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2361  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2362  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2363  *
2364  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2365  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2366  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2367  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2368  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2369  *
2370  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2371  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2372  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2373  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2374  *
2375  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2376  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2377  *
2378  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2379  *
2380  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2381  *
2382  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2383  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2384  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2385  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2386  *
2387  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2388  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2389  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2390  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2391  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2392  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2393  *
2394  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2395  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2396  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2397  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2398  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2399  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2400  *	over all channels.
2401  *
2402  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2403  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2404  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2405  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2406 
2407  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2408  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2409  *
2410  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2411  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2412  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2413  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2414  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2415  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2416  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2417  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2418  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2419  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2420  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2421  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2422  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2423  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2424  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2425  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2426  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2427  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2428  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2429  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2430  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2431  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2432  *
2433  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2434  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2435  *
2436  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2437  *
2438  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2439  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2440  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2441  *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2442  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2443  *	present.
2444  *
2445  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2446  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2447  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2448  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2449  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2450  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2451  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2452  *	each group.
2453  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2454  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2455  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2456  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2457  *	groupID data.
2458  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2459  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2460  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2461  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2462  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2463  *
2464  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2465  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2466  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2467  *	attribute must not be included).
2468  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2469  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2470  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2471  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2472  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2473  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2474  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2475  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2476  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2477  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2478  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2479  *
2480  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2481  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2482  *
2483  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2484  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2485  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2486  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2487  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2488  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2489  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2490  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2491  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2492  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2493  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2494  *	the device will decide what to use.
2495  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2496  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2497  *	attribute.
2498  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2499  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2500  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2501  *	protection.
2502  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2503  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2504  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2505  *
2506  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2507  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2508  *
2509  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2510  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2511  *
2512  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2513  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2514  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2515  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2516  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2517  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2518  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2519  *
2520  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2521  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2522  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2523  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2524  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2525  *
2526  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2527  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2528  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2529  *
2530  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2531  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2532  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2533  *
2534  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2535  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2536  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2537  *
2538  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2539  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2540  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2541  *
2542  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2543  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2544  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2545  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2546  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2547  *
2548  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
2549  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2550  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2551  *
2552  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2553  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2554  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2555  *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2556  *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2557  *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2558  *	is included as well.
2559  *
2560  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2561  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2562  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2563  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2564  *
2565  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2566  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2567  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2568  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2569  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2570  *
2571  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2572  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2573  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2574  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2575  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2576  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2577  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2578  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2579  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2580  *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2581  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2582  *
2583  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2584  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2585  *
2586  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2587  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2588  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2589  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2590  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2591  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2592  *      enforced.
2593  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2594  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2595  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2596  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2597  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2598  *
2599  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2600  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2601  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2602  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2603  *
2604  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2605  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2606  *
2607  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2608  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2609  *	invalid value.
2610  *
2611  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2612  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2613  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2614  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2615  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2616  *
2617  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2618  *	scheduler.
2619  *
2620  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2621  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2622  *	possible values.
2623  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2624  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2625  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2626  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2627  *	or per-station.
2628  *
2629  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2630  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2631  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2632  *
2633  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2634  *
2635  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2636  *	functionality.
2637  *
2638  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2639  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2640  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2641  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2642  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2643  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2644  *
2645  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2646  *	(u16).
2647  *
2648  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2649  *
2650  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2651  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2652  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2653  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2654  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2655  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2656  *
2657  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2658  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2659  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2660  *	attributes.
2661  *
2662  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2663  *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2664  *
2665  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2666  *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2667  *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2668  *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2669  *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2670  *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2671  *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2672  *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2673  *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2674  *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2675  *
2676  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2677  *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2678  *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2679  *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2680  *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2681  *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2682  *	has expired.
2683  *
2684  *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2685  *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2686  *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2687  *	disassociation is still forced.
2688  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2689  *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2690  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2691  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2692  *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2693  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2694  *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2695  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2696  *
2697  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2698  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2699  *
2700  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2701  *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2702  *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2703  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2704  *
2705  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2706  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2707  *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2708  *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2709  *
2710  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2711  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2712  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2713  *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2714  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2715  *
2716  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2717  *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2718  *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2719  *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2720  *
2721  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2722  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2723  *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2724  *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2725  *
2726  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2727  *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2728  *	is desired.
2729  *
2730  * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2731  *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2732  *
2733  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2734  *	until the color switch event.
2735  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2736  *	switching to
2737  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2738  *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2739  *
2740  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2741  *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2742  *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2743  *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2744  *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2745  *	parameters.
2746  *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2747  *
2748  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2749  *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2750  *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2751  *
2752  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2753  *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2754  *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2755  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2756  *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2757  *	radar channel.
2758  *
2759  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2760  *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2761  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2762  *
2763  * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2764  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2765  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2766  *
2767  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2768  *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2769  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2770  *	per-link information and a link ID.
2771  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2772  *	authenticate/associate.
2773  *
2774  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2775  *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2776  *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2777  *
2778  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2779  *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2780  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2781  *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2782  *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2783  *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2784  *
2785  * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2786  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2787  *
2788  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2789  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2790  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2791  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2792  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2793  *	the ack TX timestamp.
2794  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2795  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2796  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2797  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2798  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2799  *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2800  * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2801  *	(re)associations.
2802  *
2803  * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2804  *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2805  *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2806  *	reserved.
2807  *
2808  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
2809  *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
2810  *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
2811  *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
2812  * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
2813  *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
2814  *
2815  * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
2816  *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
2817  *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
2818  *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
2819  *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
2820  *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
2821  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
2822  *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
2823  *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
2824  *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
2825  *
2826  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is
2827  *	disabled.
2828  *
2829  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2830  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2831  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2832  */
2833 enum nl80211_attrs {
2834 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2835 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2836 
2837 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2838 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2839 
2840 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2841 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2842 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2843 
2844 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2845 
2846 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2847 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2848 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2849 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2850 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2851 
2852 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2853 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2854 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2855 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2856 
2857 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2858 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2859 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2860 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2861 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2862 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2863 
2864 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2865 
2866 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2867 
2868 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2869 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2870 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2871 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2872 
2873 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2874 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2875 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2876 
2877 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2878 
2879 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2880 
2881 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2882 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2883 
2884 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2885 
2886 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2887 
2888 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2889 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2890 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2891 
2892 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2893 
2894 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2895 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2896 
2897 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2898 
2899 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2900 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2901 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2902 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2903 
2904 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2905 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2906 
2907 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2908 
2909 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2910 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2911 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2912 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2913 
2914 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2915 
2916 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2917 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2918 
2919 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2920 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2921 
2922 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2923 
2924 
2925 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2926 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2927 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2928 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2929 
2930 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2931 
2932 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2933 
2934 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2935 
2936 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2937 
2938 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2939 
2940 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2941 
2942 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2943 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2944 
2945 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2946 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2947 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2948 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2949 
2950 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2951 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2952 
2953 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2954 
2955 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2956 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2957 
2958 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2959 
2960 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2961 
2962 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2963 
2964 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2965 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2966 
2967 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2968 
2969 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
2970 
2971 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
2972 
2973 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
2974 
2975 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
2976 
2977 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
2978 
2979 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
2980 
2981 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
2982 
2983 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
2984 
2985 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
2986 
2987 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2988 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
2989 
2990 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
2991 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
2992 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
2993 
2994 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
2995 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
2996 
2997 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
2998 
2999 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
3000 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
3001 
3002 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
3003 
3004 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
3005 
3006 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
3007 
3008 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
3009 
3010 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
3011 
3012 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
3013 
3014 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
3015 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
3016 
3017 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
3018 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
3019 
3020 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
3021 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
3022 
3023 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
3024 
3025 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3026 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
3027 
3028 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
3029 
3030 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
3031 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3032 
3033 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
3034 
3035 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
3036 
3037 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
3038 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
3039 
3040 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
3041 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
3042 
3043 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
3044 
3045 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
3046 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
3047 
3048 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
3049 
3050 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3051 
3052 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3053 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3054 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3055 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3056 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3057 
3058 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3059 
3060 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3061 
3062 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3063 
3064 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3065 
3066 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3067 
3068 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3069 
3070 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3071 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3072 
3073 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3074 
3075 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3076 
3077 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3078 
3079 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3080 
3081 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3082 
3083 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3084 
3085 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3086 
3087 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3088 
3089 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3090 
3091 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3092 
3093 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3094 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3095 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3096 
3097 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3098 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3099 
3100 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3101 
3102 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3103 
3104 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3105 
3106 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3107 
3108 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3109 
3110 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3111 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3112 
3113 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3114 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3115 
3116 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3117 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3118 
3119 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3120 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3121 
3122 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3123 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3124 
3125 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3126 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3127 
3128 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3129 
3130 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3131 
3132 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3133 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3134 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3135 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3136 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3137 
3138 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3139 
3140 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3141 
3142 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3143 
3144 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3145 
3146 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3147 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3148 
3149 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3150 
3151 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3152 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3153 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3154 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3155 
3156 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3157 
3158 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3159 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3160 
3161 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3162 
3163 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3164 
3165 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3166 
3167 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3168 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3169 
3170 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3171 
3172 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3173 
3174 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3175 
3176 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3177 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3178 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3179 
3180 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3181 
3182 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3183 
3184 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3185 
3186 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3187 
3188 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3189 
3190 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3191 
3192 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3193 
3194 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3195 
3196 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3197 
3198 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3199 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3200 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3201 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3202 
3203 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3204 
3205 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3206 
3207 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3208 
3209 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3210 
3211 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3212 
3213 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3214 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3215 
3216 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3217 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3218 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3219 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3220 
3221 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3222 
3223 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3224 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3225 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3226 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3227 
3228 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3229 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3230 
3231 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3232 
3233 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3234 
3235 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3236 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3237 
3238 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3239 
3240 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3241 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3242 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3243 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3244 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3245 
3246 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3247 
3248 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3249 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3250 
3251 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3252 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3253 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3254 
3255 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3256 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3257 
3258 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3259 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3260 
3261 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3262 
3263 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3264 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3265 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3266 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3267 
3268 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3269 
3270 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3271 
3272 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3273 
3274 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3275 
3276 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3277 
3278 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3279 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3280 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3281 
3282 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3283 
3284 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3285 
3286 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3287 
3288 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3289 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3290 
3291 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3292 
3293 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3294 
3295 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3296 
3297 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3298 
3299 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3300 
3301 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3302 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3303 
3304 	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3305 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3306 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3307 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3308 
3309 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3310 
3311 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3312 
3313 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3314 
3315 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3316 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3317 
3318 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3319 
3320 	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3321 
3322 	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3323 
3324 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3325 
3326 	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3327 
3328 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3329 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3330 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3331 
3332 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3333 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3334 
3335 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3336 
3337 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3338 
3339 	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3340 
3341 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3342 
3343 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3344 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3345 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3346 
3347 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3348 
3349 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3350 
3351 	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3352 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3353 
3354 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3355 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3356 	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3357 
3358 	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3359 
3360 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
3361 	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
3362 
3363 	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
3364 
3365 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED,
3366 
3367 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3368 
3369 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3370 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3371 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3372 };
3373 
3374 /* source-level API compatibility */
3375 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3376 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3377 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3378 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3379 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3380 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3381 
3382 /*
3383  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3384  * here
3385  */
3386 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3387 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3388 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3389 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3390 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3391 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3392 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3393 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3394 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3395 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3396 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3397 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3398 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3399 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3400 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3401 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3402 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3403 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3404 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3405 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3406 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3407 
3408 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3409 
3410 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3411 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3412 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3413 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3414 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3415 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3416 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3417 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3418 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3419 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3420 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3421 
3422 /*
3423  * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3424  * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3425  */
3426 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3427 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3428 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3429 
3430 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3431 
3432 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3433 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3434 
3435 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3436 
3437 /**
3438  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3439  *
3440  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3441  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3442  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3443  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3444  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3445  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3446  *	AP type interface.
3447  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3448  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3449  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3450  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3451  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3452  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3453  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3454  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3455  *	commands to create and destroy one
3456  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3457  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3458  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3459  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3460  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3461  *
3462  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3463  * to set the type of an interface.
3464  *
3465  */
3466 enum nl80211_iftype {
3467 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3468 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3469 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3470 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3471 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3472 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3473 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3474 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3475 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3476 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3477 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3478 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3479 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3480 
3481 	/* keep last */
3482 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3483 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3484 };
3485 
3486 /**
3487  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3488  *
3489  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3490  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3491  *
3492  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3493  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3494  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3495  *	with short barker preamble
3496  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3497  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3498  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3499  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3500  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3501  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3502  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3503  *	as errors.)
3504  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3505  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3506  *	previously added station into associated state
3507  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3508  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3509  */
3510 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3511 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3512 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3513 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3514 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3515 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3516 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3517 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3518 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3519 
3520 	/* keep last */
3521 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3522 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3523 };
3524 
3525 /**
3526  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3527  *
3528  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3529  * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3530  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3531  */
3532 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3533 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3534 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3535 
3536 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3537 };
3538 
3539 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3540 
3541 /**
3542  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3543  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3544  * @set: which values to set them to
3545  *
3546  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3547  */
3548 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3549 	__u32 mask;
3550 	__u32 set;
3551 } __attribute__((packed));
3552 
3553 /**
3554  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3555  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3556  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3557  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3558  */
3559 enum nl80211_he_gi {
3560 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3561 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3562 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3563 };
3564 
3565 /**
3566  * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3567  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec
3568  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec
3569  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec
3570  */
3571 enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3572 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3573 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3574 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3575 };
3576 
3577 /**
3578  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3579  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3580  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3581  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3582  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3583  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3584  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3585  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3586  */
3587 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3588 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3589 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3590 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3591 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3592 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3593 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3594 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3595 };
3596 
3597 /**
3598  * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3599  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3600  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3601  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3602  */
3603 enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3604 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3605 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3606 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3607 };
3608 
3609 /**
3610  * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3611  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3612  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3613  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3614  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3615  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3616  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3617  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3618  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3619  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3620  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3621  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3622  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3623  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3624  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3625  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3626  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3627  */
3628 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3629 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3630 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3631 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3632 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3633 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3634 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3635 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3636 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3637 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3638 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3639 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3640 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3641 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3642 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3643 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3644 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3645 };
3646 
3647 /**
3648  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3649  *
3650  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3651  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3652  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3653  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3654  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3655  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3656  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3657  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3658  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3659  *
3660  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3661  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3662  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3663  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3664  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3665  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3666  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3667  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3668  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3669  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3670  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3671  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3672  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3673  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3674  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3675  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3676  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3677  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3678  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3679  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3680  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3681  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3682  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3683  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3684  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3685  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3686  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3687  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3688  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3689  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3690  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3691  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3692  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3693  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10)
3694  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4)
3695  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate
3696  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate
3697  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate
3698  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate
3699  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate
3700  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3701  */
3702 enum nl80211_rate_info {
3703 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3704 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3705 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3706 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3707 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3708 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3709 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3710 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3711 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3712 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3713 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3714 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3715 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3716 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3717 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3718 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3719 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3720 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3721 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3722 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3723 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3724 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3725 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3726 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS,
3727 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS,
3728 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH,
3729 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH,
3730 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH,
3731 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH,
3732 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH,
3733 
3734 	/* keep last */
3735 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3736 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3737 };
3738 
3739 /**
3740  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3741  *
3742  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3743  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3744  *
3745  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3746  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3747  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3748  *	(flag)
3749  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3750  *	(flag)
3751  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3752  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3753  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3754  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3755  */
3756 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3757 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3758 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3759 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3760 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3761 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3762 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3763 
3764 	/* keep last */
3765 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3766 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3767 };
3768 
3769 /**
3770  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3771  *
3772  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3773  * when getting information about a station.
3774  *
3775  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3776  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3777  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3778  *	(u32, from this station)
3779  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3780  *	(u32, to this station)
3781  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3782  *	(u64, from this station)
3783  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3784  *	(u64, to this station)
3785  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3786  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3787  * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3788  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3789  *	(u32, from this station)
3790  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3791  *	(u32, to this station)
3792  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3793  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3794  *	(u32, to this station)
3795  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3796  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3797  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3798  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3799  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3800  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3801  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3802  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3803  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3804  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3805  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3806  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3807  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3808  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3809  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3810  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3811  *	non-peer STA
3812  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3813  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3814  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3815  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3816  * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
3817  *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3818  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3819  *	(u64)
3820  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3821  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3822  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3823  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3824  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3825  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3826  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3827  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3828  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3829  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3830  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3831  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3832  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3833  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3834  *	(u32, from this station)
3835  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3836  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3837  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3838  *	might not be fully accurate.
3839  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3840  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3841  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3842  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3843  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3844  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3845  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3846  *	of STA's association
3847  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3848  *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3849  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3850  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3851  */
3852 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3853 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3854 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3855 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3856 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3857 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3858 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3859 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3860 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3861 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3862 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3863 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3864 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3865 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3866 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3867 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3868 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3869 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3870 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3871 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3872 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3873 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3874 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3875 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3876 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3877 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3878 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3879 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3880 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3881 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3882 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3883 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3884 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3885 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3886 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3887 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3888 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3889 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3890 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3891 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3892 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3893 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3894 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3895 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3896 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3897 
3898 	/* keep last */
3899 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3900 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3901 };
3902 
3903 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3904 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3905 
3906 
3907 /**
3908  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3909  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3910  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3911  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3912  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3913  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3914  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3915  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3916  *	MSDUs (u64)
3917  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3918  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3919  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3920  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3921  */
3922 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3923 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3924 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3925 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3926 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3927 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3928 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3929 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3930 
3931 	/* keep last */
3932 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3933 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3934 };
3935 
3936 /**
3937  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3938  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3939  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3940  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3941  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3942  *      backlogged
3943  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3944  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3945  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3946  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3947  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3948  *      (only for per-phy stats)
3949  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3950  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3951  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3952  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3953  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3954  */
3955 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3956 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3957 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3958 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3959 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3960 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
3961 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
3962 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
3963 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
3964 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
3965 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
3966 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
3967 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
3968 
3969 	/* keep last */
3970 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
3971 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
3972 };
3973 
3974 /**
3975  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
3976  *
3977  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
3978  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
3979  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
3980  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
3981  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
3982  */
3983 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
3984 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
3985 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
3986 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
3987 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
3988 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
3989 };
3990 
3991 /**
3992  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
3993  *
3994  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
3995  * information about a mesh path.
3996  *
3997  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3998  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
3999  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
4000  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
4001  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
4002  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
4003  * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
4004  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
4005  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
4006  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
4007  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
4008  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
4009  *	currently defined
4010  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4011  */
4012 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
4013 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
4014 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
4015 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
4016 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
4017 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
4018 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
4019 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4020 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
4021 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
4022 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
4023 
4024 	/* keep last */
4025 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4026 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4027 };
4028 
4029 /**
4030  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
4031  *
4032  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4033  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
4034  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
4035  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
4036  *     capabilities IE
4037  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
4038  *     capabilities IE
4039  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
4040  *     capabilities IE
4041  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
4042  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
4043  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
4044  *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
4045  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
4046  *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
4047  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
4048  *	capabilities element
4049  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
4050  *	capabilities element
4051  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
4052  *	capabilities element
4053  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
4054  *	defined in EHT capabilities element
4055  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4056  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4057  */
4058 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
4059 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
4060 
4061 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
4062 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
4063 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
4064 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
4065 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
4066 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
4067 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
4068 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
4069 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
4070 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
4071 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4072 
4073 	/* keep last */
4074 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4075 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4076 };
4077 
4078 /**
4079  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4080  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4081  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4082  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4083  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4084  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4085  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4086  *	defined in 802.11n
4087  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4088  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4089  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4090  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4091  *	defined in 802.11ac
4092  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4093  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4094  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4095  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4096  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4097  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4098  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4099  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4100  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4101  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
4102  *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
4103  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
4104  *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
4105  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4106  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4107  */
4108 enum nl80211_band_attr {
4109 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4110 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4111 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4112 
4113 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4114 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4115 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4116 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4117 
4118 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4119 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4120 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4121 
4122 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4123 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4124 
4125 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
4126 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
4127 
4128 	/* keep last */
4129 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4130 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4131 };
4132 
4133 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4134 
4135 /**
4136  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4137  *
4138  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4139  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4140  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4141  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4142  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4143  * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4144  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4145  */
4146 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4147 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4148 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4149 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4150 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4151 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4152 
4153 	/* keep last */
4154 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4155 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4156 };
4157 
4158 /**
4159  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4160  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4161  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4162  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4163  *	regulatory domain.
4164  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4165  * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4166  * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4167  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4168  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4169  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4170  *	(100 * dBm).
4171  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4172  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4173  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
4174  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4175  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4176  *	channel as the control channel
4177  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4178  *	channel as the control channel
4179  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4180  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4181  *	this includes 80+80 channels
4182  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4183  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4184  *	isn't possible
4185  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4186  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4187  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4188  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4189  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4190  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4191  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4192  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4193  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4194  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4195  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4196  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4197  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4198  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4199  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4200  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4201  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4202  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4203  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4204  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4205  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4206  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4207  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4208  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4209  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4210  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4211  *	in current regulatory domain.
4212  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4213  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4214  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4215  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4216  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4217  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4218  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4219  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4220  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4221  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4222  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4223  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4224  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4225  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4226  *	in current regulatory domain.
4227  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that
4228  *	is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4229  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4230  *	currently defined
4231  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4232  *
4233  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4234  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4235  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4236  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4237  */
4238 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4239 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4240 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4241 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4242 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4243 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4244 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4245 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4246 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4247 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4248 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4249 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4250 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4251 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4252 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4253 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4254 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4255 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4256 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4257 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4258 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4259 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4260 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4261 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4262 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4263 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4264 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4265 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4266 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4267 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD,
4268 
4269 	/* keep last */
4270 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4271 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4272 };
4273 
4274 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4275 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4276 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4277 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4278 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4279 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4280 
4281 /**
4282  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4283  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4284  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4285  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4286  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4287  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4288  *	currently defined
4289  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4290  */
4291 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4292 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4293 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4294 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4295 
4296 	/* keep last */
4297 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4298 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4299 };
4300 
4301 /**
4302  * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4303  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4304  * 	regulatory domain.
4305  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4306  * 	regulatory domain.
4307  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4308  * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4309  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4310  * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4311  * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4312  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4313  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4314  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4315  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4316  */
4317 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4318 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4319 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4320 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4321 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4322 };
4323 
4324 /**
4325  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4326  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4327  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4328  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4329  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4330  * 	domain.
4331  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4332  * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4333  * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4334  * 	them to be applied.
4335  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4336  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4337  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4338  *	domain request to be processed.
4339  */
4340 enum nl80211_reg_type {
4341 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4342 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4343 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4344 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4345 };
4346 
4347 /**
4348  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4349  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4350  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4351  * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4352  * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4353  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4354  * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4355  * 	band edge.
4356  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4357  * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4358  * 	band edge.
4359  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4360  *	frequency range, in KHz.
4361  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4362  * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4363  * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4364  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4365  * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4366  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4367  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4368  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm).
4369  *	This could be negative.
4370  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4371  *	currently defined
4372  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4373  */
4374 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4375 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4376 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4377 
4378 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4379 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4380 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4381 
4382 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4383 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4384 
4385 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4386 
4387 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD,
4388 
4389 	/* keep last */
4390 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4391 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4392 };
4393 
4394 /**
4395  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4396  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4397  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4398  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4399  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4400  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4401  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4402  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4403  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4404  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4405  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4406  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4407  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4408  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4409  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4410  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4411  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4412  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4413  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4414  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4415  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4416  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4417  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the
4418  *	band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in
4419  *	enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a
4420  *	band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one
4421  *	of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the
4422  *	minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated
4423  *	within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such
4424  *	attributes will be nested within this attribute.
4425  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4426  *	attribute number currently defined
4427  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4428  */
4429 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4430 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4431 
4432 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4433 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4434 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4435 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4436 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4437 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI,
4438 
4439 	/* keep last */
4440 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4441 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4442 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4443 };
4444 
4445 /* only for backward compatibility */
4446 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4447 
4448 /**
4449  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4450  *
4451  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4452  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4453  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4454  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4455  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4456  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4457  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4458  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4459  * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4460  * 	beaconing.
4461  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4462  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4463  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4464  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4465  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4466  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4467  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4468  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4469  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4470  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4471  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed
4472  * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value
4473  */
4474 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4475 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4476 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4477 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4478 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4479 	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4480 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4481 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4482 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4483 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4484 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4485 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4486 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4487 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4488 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4489 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4490 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4491 	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ		= 1<<18,
4492 	NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT		= 1<<19,
4493 	NL80211_RRF_PSD			= 1<<20,
4494 };
4495 
4496 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4497 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4498 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4499 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4500 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4501 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4502 
4503 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4504 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4505 
4506 /**
4507  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4508  *
4509  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4510  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4511  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4512  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4513  */
4514 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4515 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4516 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4517 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4518 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4519 };
4520 
4521 /**
4522  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4523  *
4524  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4525  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4526  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4527  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4528  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4529  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4530  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4531  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4532  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4533  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4534  *	supported feature.
4535  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4536  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4537  */
4538 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4539 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4540 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4541 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4542 };
4543 
4544 /**
4545  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4546  *
4547  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4548  * when getting information about a survey.
4549  *
4550  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4551  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4552  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4553  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4554  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4555  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4556  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4557  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4558  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4559  *	channel was sensed busy
4560  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4561  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4562  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4563  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4564  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4565  *	(on this channel or globally)
4566  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4567  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4568  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4569  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4570  *	currently defined
4571  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4572  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4573  */
4574 enum nl80211_survey_info {
4575 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4576 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4577 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4578 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4579 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4580 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4581 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4582 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4583 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4584 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4585 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4586 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4587 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4588 
4589 	/* keep last */
4590 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4591 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4592 };
4593 
4594 /* keep old names for compatibility */
4595 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4596 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4597 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4598 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4599 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4600 
4601 /**
4602  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4603  *
4604  * Monitor configuration flags.
4605  *
4606  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4607  *
4608  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4609  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4610  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4611  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4612  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4613  *	overrides all other flags.
4614  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4615  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4616  *
4617  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4618  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4619  */
4620 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4621 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4622 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4623 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4624 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4625 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4626 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4627 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4628 
4629 	/* keep last */
4630 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4631 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4632 };
4633 
4634 /**
4635  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4636  *
4637  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4638  *	not known or has not been set yet.
4639  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4640  *	in Awake state all the time.
4641  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4642  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4643  *	neighbor's beacons.
4644  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4645  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4646  *	for neighbor's beacons.
4647  *
4648  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
4649  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
4650  */
4651 
4652 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4653 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4654 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4655 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4656 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4657 
4658 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4659 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4660 };
4661 
4662 /**
4663  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4664  *
4665  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4666  * active.
4667  *
4668  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4669  *
4670  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4671  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4672  *
4673  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4674  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4675  *
4676  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4677  *	millisecond units
4678  *
4679  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4680  *	on this mesh interface
4681  *
4682  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4683  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4684  *	mesh
4685  *
4686  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4687  *	point.
4688  *
4689  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4690  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4691  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4692  *	set.
4693  *
4694  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4695  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4696  *	target)
4697  *
4698  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4699  *	(in milliseconds)
4700  *
4701  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4702  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4703  *
4704  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4705  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4706  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4707  *
4708  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4709  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4710  *	reference element
4711  *
4712  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4713  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4714  *	mesh
4715  *
4716  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4717  *
4718  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4719  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4720  *
4721  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4722  *	root announcements are transmitted.
4723  *
4724  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4725  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4726  *	Announcement frames.
4727  *
4728  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4729  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4730  *	PERR element.
4731  *
4732  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4733  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4734  *
4735  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4736  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4737  *	a peer link.
4738  *
4739  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4740  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4741  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4742  *
4743  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4744  *
4745  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4746  *
4747  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4748  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4749  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4750  *
4751  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4752  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4753  *
4754  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4755  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4756  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4757  *
4758  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4759  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4760  *
4761  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4762  *
4763  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4764  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4765  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4766  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4767  *
4768  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4769  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4770  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4771  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4772  *
4773  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4774  *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4775  *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4776  *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4777  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4778  *
4779  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4780  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4781  *	in the mesh formation field.
4782  *
4783  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4784  */
4785 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4786 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4787 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4788 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4789 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4790 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4791 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4792 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4793 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4794 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4795 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4796 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4797 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4798 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4799 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4800 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4801 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4802 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4803 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4804 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4805 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4806 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4807 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4808 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4809 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4810 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4811 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4812 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4813 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4814 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4815 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4816 	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4817 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4818 
4819 	/* keep last */
4820 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4821 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4822 };
4823 
4824 /**
4825  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4826  *
4827  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4828  * changed while the mesh is active.
4829  *
4830  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4831  *
4832  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4833  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4834  *	default HWMP.
4835  *
4836  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4837  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4838  *	metric.
4839  *
4840  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4841  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4842  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4843  *	metrics in use.
4844  *
4845  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4846  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4847  *
4848  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4849  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4850  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4851  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4852  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4853  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4854  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4855  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4856  *	userspace daemon.
4857  *
4858  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4859  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4860  *	neighbor offset synchronization
4861  *
4862  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4863  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4864  *
4865  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4866  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4867  *	Default is no authentication method required.
4868  *
4869  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4870  *
4871  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4872  */
4873 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4874 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4875 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4876 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4877 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4878 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4879 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4880 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4881 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4882 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4883 
4884 	/* keep last */
4885 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4886 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4887 };
4888 
4889 /**
4890  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4891  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4892  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4893  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4894  *	disabled
4895  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4896  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4897  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4898  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4899  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4900  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4901  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4902  */
4903 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4904 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4905 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4906 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4907 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4908 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4909 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4910 
4911 	/* keep last */
4912 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4913 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4914 };
4915 
4916 enum nl80211_ac {
4917 	NL80211_AC_VO,
4918 	NL80211_AC_VI,
4919 	NL80211_AC_BE,
4920 	NL80211_AC_BK,
4921 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
4922 };
4923 
4924 /* backward compat */
4925 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
4926 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
4927 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
4928 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
4929 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
4930 
4931 /**
4932  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
4933  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4934  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
4935  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4936  *	below the control channel
4937  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4938  *	above the control channel
4939  */
4940 enum nl80211_channel_type {
4941 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
4942 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
4943 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
4944 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
4945 };
4946 
4947 /**
4948  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
4949  *
4950  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
4951  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
4952  *
4953  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
4954  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
4955  *
4956  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
4957  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
4958  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
4959  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
4960  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
4961  */
4962 enum nl80211_key_mode {
4963 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
4964 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
4965 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
4966 };
4967 
4968 /**
4969  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
4970  *
4971  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
4972  * attribute.
4973  *
4974  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4975  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
4976  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4977  *	attribute must be provided as well
4978  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4979  *	attribute must be provided as well
4980  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4981  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
4982  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4983  *	attribute must be provided as well
4984  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
4985  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
4986  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
4987  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
4988  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
4989  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
4990  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
4991  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4992  *	attribute must be provided as well
4993  */
4994 enum nl80211_chan_width {
4995 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
4996 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4997 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
4998 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
4999 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
5000 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
5001 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5002 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5003 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5004 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5005 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
5006 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
5007 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
5008 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
5009 };
5010 
5011 /**
5012  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
5013  *
5014  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
5015  *
5016  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
5017  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
5018  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
5019  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
5020  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
5021  */
5022 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
5023 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5024 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5025 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5026 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5027 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5028 };
5029 
5030 /**
5031  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
5032  *
5033  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
5034  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
5035  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
5036  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
5037  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
5038  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
5039  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
5040  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
5041  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
5042  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
5043  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
5044  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
5045  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
5046  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
5047  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
5048  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
5049  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
5050  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
5051  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
5052  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
5053  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
5054  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
5055  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
5056  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
5057  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
5058  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
5059  *	yet been received
5060  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
5061  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used!
5062  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
5063  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
5064  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
5065  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
5066  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
5067  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
5068  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
5069  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
5070  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
5071  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
5072  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
5073  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
5074  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
5075  *	is set.
5076  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
5077  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
5078  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
5079  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
5080  * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
5081  * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
5082  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
5083  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
5084  */
5085 enum nl80211_bss {
5086 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
5087 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
5088 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
5089 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5090 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5091 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5092 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5093 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5094 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5095 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5096 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5097 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5098 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5099 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5100 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5101 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5102 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5103 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5104 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5105 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5106 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5107 	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5108 	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5109 
5110 	/* keep last */
5111 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5112 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5113 };
5114 
5115 /**
5116  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5117  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5118  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5119  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5120  *	a given BSS.
5121  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5122  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5123  *
5124  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5125  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5126  */
5127 enum nl80211_bss_status {
5128 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5129 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5130 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5131 };
5132 
5133 /**
5134  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5135  *
5136  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5137  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5138  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5139  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5140  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5141  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5142  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5143  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5144  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5145  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5146  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5147  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5148  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5149  */
5150 enum nl80211_auth_type {
5151 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5152 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5153 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5154 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5155 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5156 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5157 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5158 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5159 
5160 	/* keep last */
5161 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5162 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5163 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5164 };
5165 
5166 /**
5167  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5168  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5169  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5170  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5171  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5172  */
5173 enum nl80211_key_type {
5174 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5175 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5176 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5177 
5178 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5179 };
5180 
5181 /**
5182  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5183  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5184  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5185  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5186  */
5187 enum nl80211_mfp {
5188 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5189 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5190 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5191 };
5192 
5193 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5194 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5195 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5196 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5197 };
5198 
5199 /**
5200  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5201  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5202  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5203  *	unicast key
5204  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5205  *	multicast key
5206  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5207  */
5208 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5209 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5210 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5211 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5212 
5213 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5214 };
5215 
5216 /**
5217  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5218  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5219  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5220  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5221  *	keys
5222  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5223  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5224  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5225  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5226  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5227  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5228  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5229  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5230  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5231  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5232  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5233  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5234  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5235  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5236  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5237  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5238  *
5239  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5240  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5241  */
5242 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5243 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5244 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5245 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5246 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5247 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5248 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5249 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5250 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5251 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5252 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5253 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5254 
5255 	/* keep last */
5256 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5257 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5258 };
5259 
5260 /**
5261  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5262  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5263  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5264  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5265  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5266  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5267  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5268  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5269  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5270  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5271  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5272  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5273  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5274  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5275  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5276  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5277  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5278  */
5279 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5280 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5281 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5282 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5283 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5284 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5285 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5286 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5287 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5288 
5289 	/* keep last */
5290 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5291 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5292 };
5293 
5294 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5295 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5296 
5297 /**
5298  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5299  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5300  */
5301 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5302 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5303 };
5304 
5305 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5306 /**
5307  * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5308  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5309  */
5310 struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5311 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5312 };
5313 
5314 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5315 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5316 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5317 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5318 };
5319 
5320 /**
5321  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5322  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5323  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5324  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5325  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5326  * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5327  * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5328  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5329  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5330  */
5331 enum nl80211_band {
5332 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5333 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5334 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5335 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5336 	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5337 	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5338 
5339 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5340 };
5341 
5342 /**
5343  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5344  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5345  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5346  */
5347 enum nl80211_ps_state {
5348 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5349 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5350 };
5351 
5352 /**
5353  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5354  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5355  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5356  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5357  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5358  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5359  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5360  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5361  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5362  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5363  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5364  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5365  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5366  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5367  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5368  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5369  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5370  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5371  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5372  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5373  *	checked.
5374  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5375  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5376  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5377  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5378  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5379  *	loss event
5380  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5381  *	RSSI threshold event.
5382  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5383  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5384  */
5385 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5386 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5387 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5388 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5389 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5390 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5391 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5392 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5393 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5394 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5395 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5396 
5397 	/* keep last */
5398 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5399 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5400 };
5401 
5402 /**
5403  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5404  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5405  *      configured threshold
5406  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5407  *      configured threshold
5408  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5409  */
5410 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5411 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5412 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5413 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5414 };
5415 
5416 
5417 /**
5418  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5419  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5420  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5421  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5422  */
5423 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5424 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5425 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5426 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5427 };
5428 
5429 /**
5430  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5431  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5432  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5433  */
5434 enum nl80211_tid_config {
5435 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5436 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5437 };
5438 
5439 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5440  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5441  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5442  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5443  */
5444 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5445 	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5446 	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5447 	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5448 };
5449 
5450 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5451  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5452  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5453  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5454  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5455  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5456  *	per peer instead.
5457  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates
5458  *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5459  *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5460  *	should be left untouched.
5461  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5462  *	Its type is u16.
5463  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5464  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5465  *	Its type is u8.
5466  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5467  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5468  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5469  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5470  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5471  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5472  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5473  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5474  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5475  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5476  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5477  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5478  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5479  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5480  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5481  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5482  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5483  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5484  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5485  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5486  *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5487  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5488  *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5489  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5490  *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5491  *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5492  *	station.
5493  */
5494 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5495 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5496 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5497 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5498 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5499 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5500 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5501 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5502 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5503 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5504 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5505 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5506 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5507 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5508 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5509 
5510 	/* keep last */
5511 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5512 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5513 };
5514 
5515 /**
5516  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5517  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5518  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5519  *	a zero bit are ignored
5520  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5521  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5522  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5523  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5524  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5525  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5526  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5527  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5528  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5529  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5530  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5531  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5532  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5533  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5534  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5535  */
5536 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5537 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5538 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5539 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5540 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5541 
5542 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5543 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5544 };
5545 
5546 /**
5547  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5548  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5549  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5550  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5551  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5552  *
5553  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5554  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5555  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5556  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5557  * by the kernel to userspace.
5558  */
5559 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5560 	__u32 max_patterns;
5561 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5562 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5563 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5564 } __attribute__((packed));
5565 
5566 /* only for backward compatibility */
5567 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5568 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5569 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5570 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5571 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5572 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5573 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5574 
5575 /**
5576  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5577  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5578  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5579  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5580  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5581  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5582  *	any others are even supported by the device.
5583  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5584  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5585  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5586  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5587  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5588  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5589  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5590  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5591  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5592  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5593  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5594  *
5595  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5596  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5597  *
5598  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5599  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5600  *	to the kernel when configuring.
5601  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5602  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5603  *	by the device (flag)
5604  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5605  *	done by the device) (flag)
5606  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5607  *	packet (flag)
5608  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5609  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5610  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5611  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5612  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5613  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5614  *	attribute contains the original length.
5615  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5616  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5617  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5618  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5619  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5620  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5621  *	contains the original length.
5622  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5623  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5624  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5625  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5626  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5627  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5628  *	the TCP connection.
5629  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5630  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5631  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5632  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5633  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5634  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5635  *	service
5636  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5637  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5638  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5639  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5640  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5641  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5642  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5643  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5644  *	supported by the driver (u32).
5645  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5646  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5647  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5648  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5649  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5650  *	occurred.
5651  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5652  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5653  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5654  *	these attributes must be present.  If
5655  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5656  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5657  *	channel.
5658  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5659  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5660  *
5661  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5662  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5663  */
5664 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5665 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5666 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5667 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5668 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5669 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5670 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5671 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5672 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5673 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5674 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5675 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5676 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5677 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5678 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5679 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5680 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5681 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5682 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5683 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5684 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5685 
5686 	/* keep last */
5687 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5688 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5689 };
5690 
5691 /**
5692  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5693  *
5694  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5695  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5696  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5697  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5698  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5699  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5700  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5701  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5702  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5703  *
5704  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5705  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5706  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5707  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5708  * also woken up.
5709  *
5710  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5711  * response packets might not go through correctly.
5712  */
5713 
5714 /**
5715  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5716  * @start: starting value
5717  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5718  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5719  *
5720  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5721  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5722  * in little endian.
5723  */
5724 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5725 	__u32 start, offset, len;
5726 };
5727 
5728 /**
5729  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5730  * @offset: offset of token in packet
5731  * @len: length of each token
5732  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5733  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5734  */
5735 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5736 	__u32 offset, len;
5737 	__u8 token_stream[];
5738 };
5739 
5740 /**
5741  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5742  * @min_len: minimum token length
5743  * @max_len: maximum token length
5744  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5745  */
5746 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5747 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5748 };
5749 
5750 /**
5751  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5752  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5753  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5754  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5755  *	(in network byte order)
5756  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5757  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5758  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5759  *	might require ARP querying.
5760  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5761  *	socket and port will be allocated
5762  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5763  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5764  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5765  *	of the data payload.
5766  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5767  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5768  *	advertising it is just a flag
5769  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5770  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5771  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5772  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5773  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5774  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5775  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5776  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5777  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5778  *	but on the TCP payload only.
5779  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5780  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5781  */
5782 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5783 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5784 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5785 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5786 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5787 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5788 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5789 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5790 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5791 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5792 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5793 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5794 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5795 
5796 	/* keep last */
5797 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5798 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5799 };
5800 
5801 /**
5802  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5803  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5804  * @pat: packet pattern support information
5805  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5806  *
5807  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5808  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5809  */
5810 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5811 	__u32 max_rules;
5812 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5813 	__u32 max_delay;
5814 } __attribute__((packed));
5815 
5816 /**
5817  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5818  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5819  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5820  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5821  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5822  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5823  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5824  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5825  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5826  */
5827 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5828 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5829 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5830 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5831 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5832 
5833 	/* keep last */
5834 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5835 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5836 };
5837 
5838 /**
5839  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5840  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
5841  *	in a rule are matched.
5842  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5843  *	in a rule are not matched.
5844  */
5845 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5846 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5847 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5848 };
5849 
5850 /**
5851  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5852  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5853  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5854  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5855  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5856  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5857  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5858  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5859  */
5860 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5861 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5862 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5863 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5864 
5865 	/* keep last */
5866 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5867 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5868 };
5869 
5870 /**
5871  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
5872  *
5873  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5874  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
5875  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
5876  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
5877  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
5878  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
5879  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
5880  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
5881  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
5882  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
5883  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
5884  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
5885  *	different channels may be used within this group.
5886  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5887  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
5888  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5889  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
5890  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
5891  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
5892  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
5893  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
5894  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
5895  *
5896  * Examples:
5897  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
5898  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
5899  *
5900  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
5901  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
5902  *
5903  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
5904  *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
5905  *
5906  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
5907  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
5908  *
5909  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
5910  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
5911  * that any of these groups must match.
5912  *
5913  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
5914  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
5915  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
5916  * interface type, the following group always exists:
5917  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
5918  */
5919 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
5920 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
5921 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
5922 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
5923 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
5924 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
5925 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
5926 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
5927 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
5928 
5929 	/* keep last */
5930 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
5931 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
5932 };
5933 
5934 
5935 /**
5936  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
5937  *
5938  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
5939  *	state of non existent mesh peer links
5940  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
5941  *	this mesh peer
5942  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
5943  *	from this mesh peer
5944  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
5945  *	received from this mesh peer
5946  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
5947  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
5948  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
5949  *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
5950  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
5951  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
5952  */
5953 enum nl80211_plink_state {
5954 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
5955 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
5956 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
5957 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
5958 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
5959 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
5960 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
5961 
5962 	/* keep last */
5963 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
5964 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
5965 };
5966 
5967 /**
5968  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
5969  *
5970  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
5971  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
5972  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
5973  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
5974  */
5975 enum plink_actions {
5976 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
5977 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
5978 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
5979 
5980 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
5981 };
5982 
5983 
5984 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
5985 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
5986 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
5987 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
5988 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
5989 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
5990 
5991 /**
5992  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
5993  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5994  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
5995  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
5996  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
5997  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
5998  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
5999  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
6000  */
6001 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
6002 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
6003 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
6004 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
6005 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
6006 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
6007 
6008 	/* keep last */
6009 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
6010 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
6011 };
6012 
6013 /**
6014  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
6015  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
6016  *	Beacon frames)
6017  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
6018  *	in Beacon frames
6019  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
6020  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
6021  */
6022 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
6023 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
6024 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
6025 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
6026 };
6027 
6028 /**
6029  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
6030  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
6031  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
6032  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
6033  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
6034  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
6035  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
6036  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
6037  */
6038 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
6039 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
6040 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
6041 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
6042 
6043 	/* keep last */
6044 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
6045 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
6046 };
6047 
6048 /**
6049  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
6050  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6051  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
6052  *	priority)
6053  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
6054  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
6055  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
6056  *	(internal)
6057  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
6058  *	(internal)
6059  */
6060 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
6061 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
6062 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
6063 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
6064 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
6065 
6066 	/* keep last */
6067 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
6068 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
6069 };
6070 
6071 /**
6072  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
6073  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
6074  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
6075  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
6076  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
6077  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
6078  */
6079 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
6080 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
6081 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
6082 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
6083 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
6084 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
6085 };
6086 
6087 /**
6088  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
6089  * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6090  *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6091  *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6092  */
6093 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6094 	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6095 };
6096 
6097 /**
6098  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6099  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6100  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6101  *	socket option.
6102  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6103  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6104  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6105  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6106  *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6107  *	cellular base stations.
6108  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6109  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6110  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6111  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6112  *	mode
6113  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6114  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6115  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6116  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6117  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6118  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6119  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6120  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6121  *	setting
6122  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6123  *	powersave
6124  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6125  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6126  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6127  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6128  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6129  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6130  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6131  *	states using station flags.
6132  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6133  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6134  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6135  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6136  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6137  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6138  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6139  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6140  *	still generated by the driver.
6141  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6142  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6143  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6144  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6145  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6146  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6147  *	lifetime of a BSS.
6148  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6149  *	Set IE to probe requests.
6150  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6151  *	to probe requests.
6152  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6153  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6154  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6155  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6156  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6157  *	Measurement Report action frame.
6158  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6159  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6160  *	to enable dynack.
6161  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6162  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6163  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6164  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6165  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6166  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6167  *	rts/cts handshake.
6168  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6169  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6170  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6171  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6172  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6173  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6174  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6175  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6176  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6177  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6178  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6179  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6180  *	address mask/value will be used.
6181  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6182  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6183  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6184  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6185  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6186  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6187  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6188  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6189  */
6190 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6191 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6192 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6193 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6194 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6195 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6196 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6197 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6198 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6199 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6200 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6201 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6202 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6203 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6204 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6205 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6206 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6207 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6208 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6209 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6210 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6211 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6212 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6213 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6214 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6215 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6216 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6217 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6218 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6219 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6220 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6221 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6222 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6223 };
6224 
6225 /**
6226  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6227  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6228  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6229  *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6230  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6231  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6232  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
6233  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6234  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6235  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6237  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6238  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6239  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6240  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6241  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6242  *	(if available).
6243  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6244  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
6245  *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6246  *	(if available).
6247  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6248  *	channel dwell time.
6249  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6250  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
6251  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6252  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6253  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6254  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6255  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6256  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6257  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6258  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6259  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6260  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6261  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6262  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6263  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6264  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6265  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6266  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6267  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6268  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6269  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6270  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6271  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6272  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6273  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6274  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6275  *	be supported.
6276  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6277  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6278  *	actual dwell time.
6279  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6280  *	response
6281  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6282  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6283  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6284  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6285  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6286  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6287  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6288  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6289  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6290  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6291  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6292  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6293  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6294  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6295  *	"radar detected" event.
6296  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6297  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6298  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6299  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6300  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6301  *      TXQs.
6302  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6303  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6304  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6305  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6306  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6307  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6308  *	timing measurement responder role.
6309  *
6310  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6311  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6312  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6313  *      freeze the connection.
6314  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6315  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6316  *
6317  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6318  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6319  *	scheduling.
6320  *
6321  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6322  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6323  *
6324  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports
6325  *	filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds.
6326  *
6327  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6328  *	to a station.
6329  *
6330  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6331  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6332  *
6333  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6334  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6335  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6336  *
6337  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6338  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6339  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6340  *
6341  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6342  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6343  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6344  *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6345  *
6346  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6347  *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6348  *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6349  *
6350  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6351  *
6352  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6353  *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6354  *
6355  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6356  *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6357  *
6358  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6359  *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6360  *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6361  *	included in the scan request.
6362  *
6363  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6364  *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6365  *
6366  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6367  *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6368  *
6369  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6370  *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6371  *	command).
6372  *
6373  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6374  *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6375  *
6376  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6377  *	frames transmission
6378  *
6379  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6380  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6381  *
6382  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6383  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6384  *
6385  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6386  *      exchange protocol.
6387  *
6388  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6389  *      exchange protocol.
6390  *
6391  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6392  *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6393  *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6394  *
6395  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6396  *	detection and change announcemnts.
6397  *
6398  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6399  *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6400  *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6401  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6402  *
6403  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6404  *	detection.
6405  *
6406  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6407  *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6408  *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6409  *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6410  *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6411  *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6412  *	in progress, and no active connections.
6413  *
6414  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6415  *
6416  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6417  *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6418  *
6419  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
6420  *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
6421  *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
6422  *
6423  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6424  *	handling in station mode.
6425  *
6426  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6427  *	handling in AP mode.
6428  *
6429  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6430  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6431  */
6432 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6433 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6434 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6435 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6436 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6437 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6438 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6439 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6440 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6441 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6442 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6443 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6444 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6445 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6446 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6447 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6448 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6449 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6450 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6451 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6452 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6453 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6454 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6455 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6456 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6457 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6458 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6459 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6460 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6461 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6462 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6463 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6464 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6465 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6466 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6467 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6468 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6469 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6470 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD,
6471 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6472 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6473 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6474 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6475 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6476 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6477 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6478 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6479 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6480 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6481 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6482 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6483 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6484 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6485 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6486 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6487 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6488 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6489 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6490 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6491 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6492 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6493 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6494 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6495 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6496 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6497 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6498 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6499 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
6500 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD,
6501 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6502 
6503 	/* add new features before the definition below */
6504 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6505 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6506 };
6507 
6508 /**
6509  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6510  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6511  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6512  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6513  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6514  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6515  *	to the host.
6516  *
6517  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6518  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6519  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6520  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6521  */
6522 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6523 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6524 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6525 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6526 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6527 };
6528 
6529 /**
6530  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6531  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6532  *	handled by the AP is reached.
6533  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6534  */
6535 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6536 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6537 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6538 };
6539 
6540 /**
6541  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6542  *
6543  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6544  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6545  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6546  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6547  */
6548 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6549 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6550 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6551 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6552 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6553 };
6554 
6555 /**
6556  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6557  *
6558  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6559  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6560  * requests.
6561  *
6562  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6563  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6564  * one of them can be used in the request.
6565  *
6566  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6567  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6568  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6569  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6570  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6571  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6572  *	when really needed
6573  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6574  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6575  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6576  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6577  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6578  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6579  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6580  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6581  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6582  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6583  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6584  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6585  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6586  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6587  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6588  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6589  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6590  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6591  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6592  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6593  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6594  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6595  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6596  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6597  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6598  *	impacted with this flag.
6599  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6600  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6601  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6602  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6603  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6604  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6605  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6606  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6607  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6608  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6609  *	possible.
6610  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6611  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6612  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6613  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6614  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6615  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6616  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
6617  *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
6618  *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
6619  *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
6620  *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
6621  *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
6622  *	probe requests on non PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
6623  *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
6624  *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
6625  *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
6626  */
6627 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6628 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6629 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6630 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6631 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6632 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6633 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6634 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6635 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6636 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6637 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6638 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6639 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6640 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6641 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6642 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6643 };
6644 
6645 /**
6646  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6647  *
6648  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6649  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6650  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6651  *
6652  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6653  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6654  *	in ACL to authenticate.
6655  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6656  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6657  */
6658 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6659 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6660 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6661 };
6662 
6663 /**
6664  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6665  *
6666  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6667  *
6668  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6669  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6670  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6671  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6672  */
6673 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6674 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6675 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6676 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6677 
6678 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6679 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6680 };
6681 
6682 /**
6683  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6684  *
6685  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6686  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6687  *
6688  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6689  *	now unusable.
6690  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6691  *	the channel is now available.
6692  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6693  *	change to the channel status.
6694  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6695  *	over, channel becomes usable.
6696  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6697  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6698  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6699  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6700  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6701  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6702  */
6703 enum nl80211_radar_event {
6704 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6705 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6706 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6707 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6708 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6709 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6710 };
6711 
6712 /**
6713  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6714  *
6715  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6716  *
6717  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6718  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6719  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6720  *	is therefore marked as not available.
6721  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6722  */
6723 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6724 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6725 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6726 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6727 };
6728 
6729 /**
6730  * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6731  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6732  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6733  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6734  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6735  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6736  */
6737 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6738 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6739 };
6740 
6741 /**
6742  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6743  *
6744  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6745  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6746  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6747  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6748  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6749  */
6750 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6751 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6752 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6753 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6754 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6755 	/* add other protocols before this one */
6756 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6757 };
6758 
6759 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6760 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6761 
6762 /**
6763  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6764  *
6765  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6766  *
6767  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6768  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6769  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6770  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6771  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6772  */
6773 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6774 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6775 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6776 };
6777 
6778 /*
6779  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6780  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6781  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6782  */
6783 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6784 
6785 /**
6786  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6787  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6788  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6789  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6790  *	added to this file when needed.
6791  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6792  */
6793 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6794 	__u32 vendor_id;
6795 	__u32 subcmd;
6796 };
6797 
6798 /**
6799  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6800  *
6801  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6802  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6803  *
6804  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6805  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6806  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6807  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
6808  */
6809 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6810 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6811 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6812 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6813 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
6814 };
6815 
6816 /**
6817  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6818  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6819  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6820  *	seconds (u32).
6821  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
6822  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
6823  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
6824  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
6825  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6826  *	currently defined
6827  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6828  */
6829 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6830 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6831 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6832 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6833 
6834 	/* keep last */
6835 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6836 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6837 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6838 };
6839 
6840 /**
6841  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6842  *
6843  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6844  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6845  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6846  */
6847 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6848 	__u8 band;
6849 	__s8 delta;
6850 } __attribute__((packed));
6851 
6852 /**
6853  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6854  *
6855  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
6856  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
6857  *	is requested.
6858  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
6859  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
6860  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
6861  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
6862  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
6863  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
6864  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
6865  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
6866  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
6867  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
6868  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
6869  *
6870  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
6871  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
6872  * which the driver shall use.
6873  */
6874 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
6875 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
6876 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
6877 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
6878 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
6879 
6880 	/* keep last */
6881 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
6882 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
6883 };
6884 
6885 /**
6886  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
6887  *
6888  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
6889  *
6890  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
6891  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
6892  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
6893  */
6894 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
6895 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
6896 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
6897 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
6898 
6899 	/* keep last */
6900 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
6901 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
6902 };
6903 
6904 /**
6905  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
6906  *
6907  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
6908  *
6909  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
6910  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
6911  */
6912 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
6913 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
6914 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
6915 };
6916 
6917 /**
6918  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
6919  *
6920  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
6921  *
6922  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
6923  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
6924  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
6925  */
6926 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
6927 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
6928 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
6929 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
6930 };
6931 
6932 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
6933 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
6934 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
6935 
6936 /**
6937  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
6938  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
6939  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
6940  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
6941  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
6942  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
6943  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
6944  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
6945  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
6946  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
6947  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
6948  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
6949  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
6950  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
6951  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
6952  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
6953  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
6954  *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
6955  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
6956  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
6957  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
6958  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
6959  *	This is a flag.
6960  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
6961  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
6962  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
6963  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
6964  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
6965  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
6966  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
6967  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6968  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
6969  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6970  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
6971  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
6972  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
6973  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
6974  *
6975  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
6976  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
6977  */
6978 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
6979 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
6980 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
6981 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
6982 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
6983 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
6984 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
6985 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
6986 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
6987 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
6988 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
6989 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
6990 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
6991 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
6992 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
6993 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
6994 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
6995 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
6996 
6997 	/* keep last */
6998 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
6999 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
7000 };
7001 
7002 /**
7003  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
7004  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
7005  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
7006  *	This is a flag.
7007  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
7008  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
7009  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
7010  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
7011  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
7012  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
7013  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
7014  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
7015  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
7016  */
7017 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
7018 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
7019 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
7020 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
7021 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
7022 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
7023 
7024 	/* keep last */
7025 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
7026 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
7027 };
7028 
7029 /**
7030  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
7031  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
7032  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
7033  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
7034  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7035  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
7036  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
7037  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7038  *
7039  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
7040  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
7041  */
7042 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
7043 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
7044 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
7045 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
7046 
7047 	/* keep last */
7048 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
7049 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
7050 };
7051 
7052 /**
7053  * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
7054  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
7055  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
7056  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
7057  */
7058 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
7059 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
7060 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
7061 };
7062 
7063 /**
7064  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
7065  *	responder attributes
7066  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7067  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
7068  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
7069  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
7070  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7071  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
7072  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
7073  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7074  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7075  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
7076  */
7077 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
7078 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7079 
7080 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
7081 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7082 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7083 
7084 	/* keep last */
7085 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7086 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7087 };
7088 
7089 /*
7090  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
7091  *
7092  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
7093  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
7094  *
7095  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7096  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
7097  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
7098  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
7099  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
7100  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
7101  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
7102  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
7103  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
7104  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
7105  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
7106  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
7107  *	phase with the responder (u32)
7108  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
7109  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
7110  *	FTM slot (u32)
7111  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7112  *	scheduled window (u32)
7113  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7114  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7115  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7116  */
7117 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7118 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7119 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7120 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7121 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7122 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7123 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7124 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7125 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7126 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7127 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7128 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7129 
7130 	/* keep last */
7131 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7132 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7133 };
7134 
7135 /**
7136  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7137  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7138  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7139  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7140  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7141  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7142  */
7143 enum nl80211_preamble {
7144 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7145 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7146 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7147 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7148 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7149 };
7150 
7151 /**
7152  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7153  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7154  *	these numbers also for attributes
7155  *
7156  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7157  *
7158  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7159  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7160  */
7161 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7162 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7163 
7164 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7165 
7166 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7167 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7168 };
7169 
7170 /**
7171  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7172  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7173  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7174  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7175  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7176  *	reason may be available in the response data
7177  */
7178 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7179 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7180 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7181 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7182 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7183 };
7184 
7185 /**
7186  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7187  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7188  *
7189  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7190  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7191  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7192  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7193  *	(flag attribute)
7194  *
7195  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7196  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7197  */
7198 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7199 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7200 
7201 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7202 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7203 
7204 	/* keep last */
7205 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7206 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7207 };
7208 
7209 /**
7210  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7211  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7212  *
7213  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7214  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7215  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7216  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7217  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7218  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7219  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7220  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7221  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7222  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7223  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7224  *	(u64, usec)
7225  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7226  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7227  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7228  *	result.
7229  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7230  *
7231  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7232  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7233  */
7234 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7235 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7236 
7237 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7238 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7239 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7240 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7241 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7242 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7243 
7244 	/* keep last */
7245 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7246 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7247 };
7248 
7249 /**
7250  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7251  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7252  *
7253  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7254  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7255  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7256  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7257  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7258  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7259  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7260  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7261  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7262  *
7263  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7264  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7265  */
7266 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7267 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7268 
7269 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7270 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7271 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7272 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7273 
7274 	/* keep last */
7275 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7276 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7277 };
7278 
7279 /**
7280  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7281  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7282  *
7283  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7284  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7285  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7286  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7287  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7288  *	measurement results
7289  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7290  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7291  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7292  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7293  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7294  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7295  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7296  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7297  *	sub-attributes taken from
7298  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7299  *
7300  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7301  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7302  */
7303 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7304 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7305 
7306 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7307 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7308 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7309 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7310 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7311 
7312 	/* keep last */
7313 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7314 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7315 };
7316 
7317 /**
7318  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7319  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7320  *
7321  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7322  *	is supported
7323  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7324  *	mode is supported
7325  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7326  *	data can be requested during the measurement
7327  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7328  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7329  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7330  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7331  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7332  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7333  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7334  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7335  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7336  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7337  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7338  *	is valid)
7339  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7340  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7341  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7342  *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7343  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7344  *	if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7345  *
7346  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7347  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7348  */
7349 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7350 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7351 
7352 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7353 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7354 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7355 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7356 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7357 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7358 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7359 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7360 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7361 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7362 
7363 	/* keep last */
7364 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7365 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7366 };
7367 
7368 /**
7369  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7370  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7371  *
7372  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7373  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7374  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7375  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7376  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7377  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7378  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7379  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7380  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7381  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7382  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7383  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7384  *	requested per burst
7385  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7386  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7387  *	(u8, default 3)
7388  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7389  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7390  *	(flag)
7391  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7392  *	measurement (flag).
7393  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7394  *	mutually exclusive.
7395  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7396  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7397  *	ranging will be used.
7398  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based
7399  *	ranging measurement (flag)
7400  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7401  *	mutually exclusive.
7402  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7403  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7404  *	ranging will be used.
7405  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7406  *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7407  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7408  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7409  *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7410  *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7411  *
7412  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7413  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7414  */
7415 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7416 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7417 
7418 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7419 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7420 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7421 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7422 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7423 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7424 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7425 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7426 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7427 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7428 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7429 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7430 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7431 
7432 	/* keep last */
7433 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7434 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7435 };
7436 
7437 /**
7438  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7439  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7440  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7441  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7442  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7443  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7444  *	try and get no response)
7445  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7446  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7447  *	received
7448  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7449  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7450  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7451  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7452  */
7453 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7454 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7455 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7456 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7457 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7458 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7459 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7460 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7461 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7462 };
7463 
7464 /**
7465  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7466  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7467  *
7468  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7469  *	(u32, optional)
7470  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7471  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7472  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7473  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7474  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7475  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7476  *	that were acknowleged (u32, optional)
7477  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7478  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7479  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7480  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7481  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7482  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7483  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7484  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7485  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7486  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7487  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7488  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7489  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7490  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7491  *	attributes)
7492  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7493  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7494  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7495  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7496  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7497  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7498  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7499  *	optional)
7500  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7501  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7502  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7503  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7504  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7505  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7506  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7507  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7508  *	Type 8.
7509  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7510  *	(binary, optional);
7511  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7512  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7513  *	Type 11.
7514  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7515  *
7516  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7517  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7518  */
7519 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7520 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7521 
7522 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7523 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7524 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7525 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7526 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7527 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7528 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7529 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7530 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7531 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7532 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7533 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7534 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7535 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7536 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7537 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7538 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7539 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7540 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7541 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7542 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7543 
7544 	/* keep last */
7545 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7546 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7547 };
7548 
7549 /**
7550  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7551  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7552  *
7553  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7554  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7555  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7556  *	tx power offset.
7557  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7558  *	values used by members of the SRG.
7559  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7560  *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7561  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7562  *
7563  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7564  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7565  */
7566 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7567 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7568 
7569 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7570 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7571 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7572 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7573 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7574 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7575 
7576 	/* keep last */
7577 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7578 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7579 };
7580 
7581 /**
7582  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7583  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7584  *
7585  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7586  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7587  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7588  *
7589  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7590  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7591  */
7592 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7593 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7594 
7595 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7596 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7597 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7598 
7599 	/* keep last */
7600 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7601 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7602 };
7603 
7604 /**
7605  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7606  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7607  *
7608  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7609  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7610  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7611  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7612  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7613  *
7614  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7615  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7616  */
7617 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7618 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7619 
7620 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7621 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7622 
7623 	/* keep last */
7624 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7625 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7626 };
7627 
7628 /**
7629  * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7630  * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7631  *
7632  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7633  *
7634  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7635  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7636  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7637  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled.
7638  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7639  *	frame including the headers.
7640  *
7641  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7642  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7643  */
7644 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7645 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7646 
7647 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7648 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7649 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7650 
7651 	/* keep last */
7652 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7653 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7654 };
7655 
7656 /*
7657  * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7658  * mandatory fields.
7659  */
7660 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7661 
7662 /**
7663  * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7664  *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7665  *
7666  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7667  *
7668  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7669  *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7670  *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is
7671  *	disabled.
7672  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7673  *	frame template (binary).
7674  *
7675  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7676  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7677  */
7678 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7679 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7680 
7681 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7682 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7683 
7684 	/* keep last */
7685 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7686 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7687 		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7688 };
7689 
7690 /**
7691  * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7692  *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7693  *	used.
7694  *
7695  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7696  *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7697  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7698  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7699  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7700  *	can be used.
7701  */
7702 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7703 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7704 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7705 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7706 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7707 };
7708 
7709 /**
7710  * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7711  *
7712  * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7713  *
7714  */
7715 enum nl80211_sar_type {
7716 	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7717 
7718 	/* add new type here */
7719 
7720 	/* Keep last */
7721 	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7722 };
7723 
7724 /**
7725  * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7726  *
7727  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7728  *
7729  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7730  *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7731  *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7732  *
7733  *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7734  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7735  *
7736  *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7737  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7738  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7739  *
7740  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7741  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7742  *
7743  * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7744  */
7745 enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7746 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7747 
7748 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7749 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7750 
7751 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7752 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7753 };
7754 
7755 /**
7756  * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7757  *
7758  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7759  *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7760  *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7761  *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7762  *
7763  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7764  *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7765  *	is applied to this range.
7766  *
7767  *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7768  *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7769  *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7770  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7771  *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7772  *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7773  *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7774  *
7775  *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7776  *
7777  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7778  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7779  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7780  *
7781  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7782  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7783  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7784  *
7785  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7786  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7787  */
7788 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7789 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7790 
7791 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7792 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7793 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7794 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7795 
7796 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7797 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7798 };
7799 
7800 /**
7801  * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
7802  * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
7803  * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
7804  * MBSSID and EMA.
7805  * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
7806  * features.
7807  *
7808  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7809  *
7810  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
7811  *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
7812  *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
7813  *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
7814  *
7815  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
7816  *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
7817  *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
7818  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
7819  *	a non-zero value.
7820  *
7821  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
7822  *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
7823  *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
7824  *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
7825  *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
7826  *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
7827  *
7828  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
7829  *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
7830  *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
7831  *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
7832  *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
7833  *	the interface index of the same.
7834  *
7835  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
7836  *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
7837  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
7838  *
7839  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7840  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7841  */
7842 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
7843 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
7844 
7845 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
7846 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
7847 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
7848 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
7849 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
7850 
7851 	/* keep last */
7852 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
7853 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7854 };
7855 
7856 /**
7857  * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
7858  *
7859  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
7860  *	authentication.
7861  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
7862  *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
7863  *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
7864  *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
7865  *	userspace.
7866  */
7867 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
7868 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
7869 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
7870 };
7871 
7872 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
7873